1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2025 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26
27 /**
28 * DOC: Introduction
29 *
30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33 * drivers.
34 */
35
36 /**
37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38 *
39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44 * tasklet function.
45 *
46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48 */
49
50 /**
51 * DOC: Warning
52 *
53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55 */
56
57 /**
58 * DOC: Frame format
59 *
60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63 * hardware.
64 *
65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66 *
67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69 *
70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72 */
73
74 /**
75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76 *
77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81 *
82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83 * suspend.
84 *
85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86 *
87 */
88
89 /**
90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91 *
92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94 * different stations/interfaces.
95 *
96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98 * handler.
99 *
100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103 *
104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106 *
107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109 * driver op.
110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113 *
114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
119 *
120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124 * .release_buffered_frames().
125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128 */
129
130 /**
131 * DOC: HW timestamping
132 *
133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135 *
136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140 *
141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145 */
146 struct device;
147
148 /**
149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150 *
151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153 */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
160
161 /**
162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167 */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
173 };
174
175 /**
176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177 *
178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180 *
181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190 */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 u16 txop;
193 u16 cw_min;
194 u16 cw_max;
195 u8 aifs;
196 bool acm;
197 bool uapsd;
198 bool mu_edca;
199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208
209 /**
210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218 * bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220 * was changed.
221 */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
224 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
225 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
226 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
227 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF = BIT(4),
228 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP = BIT(5),
229 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING = BIT(6),
230 };
231
232 /**
233 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236 * (otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237 */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242
243 /**
244 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245 *
246 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248 *
249 * @def: the channel definition
250 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252 * for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262 */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267
268 int radio_idx;
269 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270
271 bool radar_enabled;
272
273 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275
276 /**
277 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
281 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288 * for changes/removal.)
289 */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294
295 /**
296 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297 *
298 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
300 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301 * done.
302 *
303 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307 */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314
315 /**
316 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317 *
318 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320 *
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322 * also implies a change in the AID.
323 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
333 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346 * changed
347 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351 * context had been assigned.
352 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355 * keep alive) changed.
356 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364 * status changed.
365 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368 */
369 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
370 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
371 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
372 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
373 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
374 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
375 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
376 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
377 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
378 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
379 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
380 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
381 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
382 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
383 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
384 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
385 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
386 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
387 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
388 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
389 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
390 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
391 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
392 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
393 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
394 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
395 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
396 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
397 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
398 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
399 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
400 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
401 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
402 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS = BIT_ULL(33),
403 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM = BIT_ULL(34),
404 BSS_CHANGED_TPE = BIT_ULL(35),
405
406 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
407 };
408
409 /*
410 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
411 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
412 * filtering will be disabled.
413 */
414 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
415
416 /**
417 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
418 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
419 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
420 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
421 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
422 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
423 * once each time the timeout triggers.
424 */
425 enum ieee80211_event_type {
426 RSSI_EVENT,
427 MLME_EVENT,
428 BAR_RX_EVENT,
429 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
430 };
431
432 /**
433 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
434 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
435 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
436 */
437 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
438 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
439 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
440 };
441
442 /**
443 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
444 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
445 */
446 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
447 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
448 };
449
450 /**
451 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
452 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
453 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
454 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
455 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
456 */
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
458 AUTH_EVENT,
459 ASSOC_EVENT,
460 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
461 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
462 };
463
464 /**
465 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
466 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
467 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
468 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
469 */
470 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
471 MLME_SUCCESS,
472 MLME_DENIED,
473 MLME_TIMEOUT,
474 };
475
476 /**
477 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
478 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
479 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
480 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
481 */
482 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
483 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
484 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
485 u16 reason;
486 };
487
488 /**
489 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
490 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
491 * @tid: the tid
492 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
493 */
494 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
495 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
496 u16 tid;
497 u16 ssn;
498 };
499
500 /**
501 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
502 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
503 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
504 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
505 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
506 * @u:union holding the fields above
507 */
508 struct ieee80211_event {
509 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
510 union {
511 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
512 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
513 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
514 } u;
515 };
516
517 /**
518 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
519 *
520 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
521 *
522 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
523 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
524 */
525 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
526 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
527 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
528 };
529
530 /**
531 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
532 *
533 * @lci: LCI subelement content
534 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
535 * @lci_len: LCI data length
536 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
537 */
538 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
539 const u8 *lci;
540 const u8 *civicloc;
541 size_t lci_len;
542 size_t civicloc_len;
543 };
544
545 /**
546 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
547 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
548 *
549 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
550 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551 */
552 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
553 u32 min_interval;
554 u32 max_interval;
555 };
556
557 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ 5
558 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
559 bool valid;
560 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
561 u8 count;
562 };
563
564 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ 16
565 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
566 bool valid;
567 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
568 u8 count, n;
569 };
570
571 /**
572 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
573 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
574 * (indexed by TX power category)
575 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
576 * 160, 320 MHz each
577 * (indexed by TX power category)
578 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
579 * subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
580 * (indexed by TX power category)
581 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
582 * each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
583 * (indexed by TX power category)
584 */
585 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
586 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
587 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
588 };
589
590 /**
591 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
592 *
593 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
594 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
595 *
596 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
597 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
598 * when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
599 * necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
600 * responses.
601 * @addr: (link) address used locally
602 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
603 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
604 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
605 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
606 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
607 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
608 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
609 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
610 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
613 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
614 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
615 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
616 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
617 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
618 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
619 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
620 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
621 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
622 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
623 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
624 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
625 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
626 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
627 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
628 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
629 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
630 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
631 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
632 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
633 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
634 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
635 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
636 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
637 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
638 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
639 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
640 * the current band.
641 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
642 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
643 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
644 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
645 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
646 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
647 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
648 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
649 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
650 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
651 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
652 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
653 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
654 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
655 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
656 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
657 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
658 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
659 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
660 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
661 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
662 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
663 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
664 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
665 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
666 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
667 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
668 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
669 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
670 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
671 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
672 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
673 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
674 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
675 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
676 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
677 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
678 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
679 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
680 * station.
681 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
682 * responder functionality.
683 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
684 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
685 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
686 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
687 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
688 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
689 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
690 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
691 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
692 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
693 * connected to (STA)
694 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
695 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
696 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
697 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
698 * interval.
699 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
700 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
701 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
702 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
703 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
704 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
705 * @epcs_support: does this BSS support EPCS
706 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
707 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
708 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
709 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
710 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
711 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
712 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
713 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
714 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
715 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
716 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
717 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
718 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
719 * beamformer
720 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
721 * beamformee
722 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
723 * beamformer
724 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
725 * beamformee
726 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
727 * beamformer
728 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
729 * beamformee
730 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
731 * beamformer
732 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
733 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
734 * bandwidth
735 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
736 * beamformer
737 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
738 * beamformee
739 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
740 * beamformer
741 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
742 * reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
743 * bandwidth
744 * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
745 * information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
746 * beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
747 * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
748 * that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
749 * its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
750 * link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
751 * bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
752 * link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
753 * In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
754 * be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
755 * the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
756 * (as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
757 */
758 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
759 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
760 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
761
762 const u8 *bssid;
763 unsigned int link_id;
764 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
765 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
766 bool uora_exists;
767 u8 uora_ocw_range;
768 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
769 bool he_support;
770 bool twt_requester;
771 bool twt_responder;
772 bool twt_protected;
773 bool twt_broadcast;
774 /* erp related data */
775 bool use_cts_prot;
776 bool use_short_preamble;
777 bool use_short_slot;
778 bool enable_beacon;
779 u8 dtim_period;
780 u16 beacon_int;
781 u16 assoc_capability;
782 u64 sync_tsf;
783 u32 sync_device_ts;
784 u8 sync_dtim_count;
785 u32 basic_rates;
786 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
787 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
788 u16 ht_operation_mode;
789 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
790 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
791 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
792 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
793 struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
794 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
795 bool qos;
796 bool hidden_ssid;
797 int txpower;
798 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
799 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
800 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
801 u16 max_idle_period;
802 bool protected_keep_alive;
803 bool ftm_responder;
804 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
805 /* Multiple BSSID data */
806 bool nontransmitted;
807 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
808 u8 bssid_index;
809 u8 bssid_indicator;
810 bool ema_ap;
811 u8 profile_periodicity;
812 struct {
813 u32 params;
814 u16 nss_set;
815 } he_oper;
816 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
817 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
818 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
819 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
820 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
821 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
822
823 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
824
825 u8 pwr_reduction;
826 bool eht_support;
827 bool epcs_support;
828 bool csa_active;
829
830 bool mu_mimo_owner;
831 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
832
833 bool color_change_active;
834 u8 color_change_color;
835
836 bool ht_ldpc;
837 bool vht_ldpc;
838 bool he_ldpc;
839 bool vht_su_beamformer;
840 bool vht_su_beamformee;
841 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
842 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
843 bool he_su_beamformer;
844 bool he_su_beamformee;
845 bool he_mu_beamformer;
846 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
847 bool eht_su_beamformer;
848 bool eht_su_beamformee;
849 bool eht_mu_beamformer;
850 bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
851 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
852 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
853 };
854
855 /**
856 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
857 *
858 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
859 *
860 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
861 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
862 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
863 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
864 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
865 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
866 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
867 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
868 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
869 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
870 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
871 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
872 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
873 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
874 * station
875 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
876 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
877 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
878 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
879 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
880 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
881 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
882 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
883 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
884 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
885 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
886 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
887 * hardware queue.
888 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
889 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
890 * is for the whole aggregation.
891 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
892 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
893 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
894 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
895 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
896 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
897 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
898 * off-channel operation.
899 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
900 * (header conversion)
901 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
902 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
903 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
904 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
905 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
906 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
907 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
908 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
909 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
910 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
911 * queue gets full.
912 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
913 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
914 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
915 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
916 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
917 * should kick the MLME state machine.
918 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
919 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
920 * status to user space)
921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
922 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
923 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
924 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
925 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
926 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
927 * handled properly by the device.
928 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
929 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
930 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
931 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
932 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
933 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
934 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
935 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
936 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
937 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
938 * PS-Poll responses.
939 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
940 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
941 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
942 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
943 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
944 * monitor injection).
945 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
946 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
947 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
948 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
949 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
950 *
951 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
952 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
953 */
954 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
955 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
956 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
957 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
958 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
959 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
960 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
961 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
962 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
963 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
964 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
965 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
966 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
967 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
968 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
969 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
970 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
971 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
972 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
973 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
974 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
975 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
976 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
977 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
978 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
979 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
980 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
981 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
982 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
983 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
984 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
985 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
986 };
987
988 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
989
990 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
991
992 /**
993 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
994 *
995 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
996 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
997 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
998 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
999 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
1000 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1002 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1003 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1004 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1005 * it can be sent out.
1006 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1007 * has already been assigned to this frame.
1008 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1009 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1010 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1011 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1012 * for sequence number assignment
1013 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1014 * which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1015 * operation on the interface.
1016 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1017 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1018 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1019 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1020 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1021 * it's intended for an MLD.
1022 *
1023 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1024 */
1025 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1026 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
1027 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
1028 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
1029 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
1030 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
1031 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
1032 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
1033 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
1034 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
1035 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
1036 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK = BIT(10),
1037 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
1038 };
1039
1040 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
1041 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
1042 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1043 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1044
1045 /**
1046 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1047 *
1048 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1049 *
1050 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1051 */
1052 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1053 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1054 };
1055
1056 /*
1057 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1058 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1059 */
1060 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
1061 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
1062 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
1063 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
1064 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
1065 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
1066 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
1067 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1068
1069 /**
1070 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1071 * Rate Control algorithm.
1072 *
1073 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1074 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1075 *
1076 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1077 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1078 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1079 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1080 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1081 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1082 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1083 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1084 * Greenfield mode.
1085 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1086 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1087 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1088 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
1089 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1090 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1091 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1092 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1093 */
1094 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1095 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1096 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1097 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1098
1099 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1100 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1101 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1102 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1103 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1104 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1105 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1106 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1107 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1108 };
1109
1110
1111 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1112 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1113
1114 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1115 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1116
1117 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1118 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1119
1120 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1121 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1122
1123 /**
1124 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1125 *
1126 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1127 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1128 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1129 *
1130 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1131 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1132 *
1133 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1134 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1135 *
1136 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1137 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1138 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1139 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1140 * information::
1141 *
1142 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1143 *
1144 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1145 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1146 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1147 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1148 * information should then contain::
1149 *
1150 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1151 *
1152 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1153 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1154 */
1155 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1156 s8 idx;
1157 u16 count:5,
1158 flags:11;
1159 } __packed;
1160
1161 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1162
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1163 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1164 {
1165 return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1166 }
1167
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1168 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1169 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1170 {
1171 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1172 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1173 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1174 }
1175
1176 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1177 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1178 {
1179 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1180 }
1181
1182 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1183 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1184 {
1185 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1186 }
1187
1188 /**
1189 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1190 *
1191 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1192 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1193 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1194 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1195 *
1196 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1197 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1198 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1199 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1200 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1201 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1202 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1203 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1204 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1205 * @control: union part for control data
1206 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1207 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1208 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1209 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1210 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1211 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1212 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1213 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1214 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1215 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1216 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1217 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1218 * @pad: padding
1219 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1220 * @status: union part for status data
1221 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1222 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1223 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1224 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1225 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1226 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1227 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1228 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1229 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1230 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1231 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1232 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1233 */
1234 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1235 /* common information */
1236 u32 flags;
1237 u32 band:3,
1238 status_data_idr:1,
1239 status_data:13,
1240 hw_queue:4,
1241 tx_time_est:10;
1242 /* 1 free bit */
1243
1244 union {
1245 struct {
1246 union {
1247 /* rate control */
1248 struct {
1249 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1250 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1251 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1252 u8 use_rts:1;
1253 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1254 u8 short_preamble:1;
1255 u8 skip_table:1;
1256
1257 /* for injection only (bitmap) */
1258 u8 antennas:2;
1259
1260 /* 14 bits free */
1261 };
1262 /* only needed before rate control */
1263 unsigned long jiffies;
1264 };
1265 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1266 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1267 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1268 u32 flags;
1269 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1270 } control;
1271 struct {
1272 u64 cookie;
1273 } ack;
1274 struct {
1275 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1276 s32 ack_signal;
1277 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1278 u8 ampdu_len;
1279 u8 antenna;
1280 u8 pad;
1281 u16 tx_time;
1282 u8 flags;
1283 u8 pad2;
1284 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1285 } status;
1286 struct {
1287 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1288 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1289 u8 pad[4];
1290
1291 void *rate_driver_data[
1292 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1293 };
1294 void *driver_data[
1295 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1296 };
1297 };
1298
1299 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1300 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1301 {
1302 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1303 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1304 */
1305 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1306 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1307 }
1308
1309 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1310 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1311 {
1312 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1313 }
1314
1315 /***
1316 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1317 *
1318 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1319 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1320 *
1321 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1322 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1323 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1324 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1325 * that was used when sending the packet.
1326 */
1327 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1328 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1329 u8 try_count;
1330 u8 tx_power_idx;
1331 };
1332
1333 /**
1334 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1335 *
1336 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1337 * @info: Basic tx status information
1338 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1339 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1340 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1341 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1342 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1343 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1344 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1345 */
1346 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1347 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1348 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1349 struct sk_buff *skb;
1350 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1351 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1352 u8 n_rates;
1353
1354 struct list_head *free_list;
1355 };
1356
1357 /**
1358 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1359 *
1360 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1361 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1362 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1363 *
1364 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1365 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1366 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1367 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1368 */
1369 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1370 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1371 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1372 const u8 *common_ies;
1373 size_t common_ie_len;
1374 };
1375
1376
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1377 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1378 {
1379 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1380 }
1381
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1382 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1383 {
1384 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1385 }
1386
1387 /**
1388 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1389 *
1390 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1391 *
1392 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1393 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1394 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1395 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1396 *
1397 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1398 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1399 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1400 */
1401 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1402 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1403 {
1404 int i;
1405
1406 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1407 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1408 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1409 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1410 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1411 /* clear the rate counts */
1412 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1413 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1414 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1415 }
1416
1417
1418 /**
1419 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1420 *
1421 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1422 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1423 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1424 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1425 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1426 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1427 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1428 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1429 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1430 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1431 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1432 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1433 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1434 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1435 * de-duplication by itself.
1436 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1437 * the frame.
1438 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1439 * the frame.
1440 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1441 * field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1442 * where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1443 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1444 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1445 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1446 * merging.
1447 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1448 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1449 * (including FCS) was received.
1450 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1451 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1452 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1453 * is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1454 * @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1455 * %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1456 * reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1457 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1458 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1459 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1460 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1461 * each A-MPDU
1462 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1463 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1464 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1465 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1466 * on this subframe
1467 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1468 * done by the hardware
1469 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1470 * processing it in any regular way.
1471 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1472 * them for sniffing purposes.
1473 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1474 * monitor interfaces.
1475 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1476 * them for sniffing purposes.
1477 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1478 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1479 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1480 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1481 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1482 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1483 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1484 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1485 * interleaved with other frames.
1486 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1487 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1488 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1489 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1490 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1491 * in the skb.
1492 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1493 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1494 * the first subframe.
1495 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1496 * be done in the hardware.
1497 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1498 * frame
1499 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1500 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1501 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1502 *
1503 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1504 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1505 * - DATA3_CODING
1506 * - DATA5_GI
1507 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1508 * - DATA6_NSTS
1509 * - DATA3_STBC
1510 *
1511 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1512 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1513 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1514 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1515 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1516 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1517 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1518 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1519 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1520 * hardware or driver)
1521 */
1522 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1523 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1524 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1525 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(2),
1526 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1527 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1528 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1529 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1530 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64 = BIT(7),
1531 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1532 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1533 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1534 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1535 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1536 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1537 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1538 /* one free bit at 15 */
1539 RX_FLAG_MACTIME = BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1540 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = 1 << 16,
1541 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = 2 << 16,
1542 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = 3 << 16,
1543 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1544 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1545 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20),
1546 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1547 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1548 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1549 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1550 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1551 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1552 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1553 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1554 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1555 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1556 };
1557
1558 /**
1559 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1560 *
1561 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1562 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1563 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1564 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1565 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1566 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1567 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1568 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1569 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1570 */
1571 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1572 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1573 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1574 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1575 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1576 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1577 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1578 };
1579
1580 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1581
1582 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1583 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1584 RX_ENC_HT,
1585 RX_ENC_VHT,
1586 RX_ENC_HE,
1587 RX_ENC_EHT,
1588 };
1589
1590 /**
1591 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1592 *
1593 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1594 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1595 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1596 *
1597 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1598 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1599 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1600 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1601 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1602 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1603 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1604 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1605 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1606 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1607 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1608 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1609 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1610 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1611 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1612 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1613 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1614 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1615 * values were filled.
1616 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1617 * support dB or unspecified units)
1618 * @antenna: antenna used
1619 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1620 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1621 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1622 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1623 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1624 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1625 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1626 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1627 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1628 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1629 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1630 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1631 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1632 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1633 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1634 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1635 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1636 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1637 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1638 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1639 * @link_valid.
1640 */
1641 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1642 u64 mactime;
1643 union {
1644 u64 boottime_ns;
1645 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1646 };
1647 u32 device_timestamp;
1648 u32 ampdu_reference;
1649 u32 flag;
1650 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1651 u8 enc_flags;
1652 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1653 union {
1654 struct {
1655 u8 he_ru:3;
1656 u8 he_gi:2;
1657 u8 he_dcm:1;
1658 };
1659 struct {
1660 u8 ru:4;
1661 u8 gi:2;
1662 } eht;
1663 };
1664 u8 rate_idx;
1665 u8 nss;
1666 u8 rx_flags;
1667 u8 band;
1668 u8 antenna;
1669 s8 signal;
1670 u8 chains;
1671 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1672 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1673 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1674 };
1675
1676 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1677 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1678 {
1679 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1680 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1681 }
1682
1683 /**
1684 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1685 *
1686 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1687 *
1688 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1689 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1690 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1691 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1692 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1693 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1694 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1695 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1696 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1697 * for more.
1698 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1699 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1700 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1701 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1702 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1703 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1704 * operating channel.
1705 */
1706 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1707 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1708 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1709 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1710 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1711 };
1712
1713
1714 /**
1715 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1716 *
1717 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1718 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1719 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1720 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1721 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1722 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1723 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1724 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1725 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1726 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1727 */
1728 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1729 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1730 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1731 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1732 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1733 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1734 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1735 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1736 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1737 };
1738
1739 /**
1740 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1741 *
1742 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1743 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1744 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1745 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1746 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1747 */
1748 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1749 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1750 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1751 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1752 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1753
1754 /* keep last */
1755 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1756 };
1757
1758 /**
1759 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1760 *
1761 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1762 *
1763 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1764 *
1765 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1766 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1767 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1768 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1769 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1770 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1771 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1772 *
1773 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1774 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1775 *
1776 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1777 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1778 *
1779 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1780 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1781 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1782 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1783 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1784 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1785 *
1786 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1787 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1788 * configured for an HT channel.
1789 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1790 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1791 */
1792 struct ieee80211_conf {
1793 u32 flags;
1794 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1795
1796 u16 listen_interval;
1797 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1798
1799 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1800
1801 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1802 bool radar_enabled;
1803 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1804 };
1805
1806 /**
1807 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1808 *
1809 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1810 * operation.
1811 *
1812 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1813 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1814 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1815 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1816 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1817 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1818 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1819 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1820 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1821 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1822 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1823 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1824 * channel, expressed in TU.
1825 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1826 */
1827 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1828 u64 timestamp;
1829 u32 device_timestamp;
1830 bool block_tx;
1831 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1832 u8 count;
1833 u8 link_id;
1834 u32 delay;
1835 };
1836
1837 /**
1838 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1839 *
1840 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1841 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1842 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1843 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1844 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1845 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1846 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1847 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1848 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1849 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1850 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1851 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1852 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1853 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1854 * enabled for the interface.
1855 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1856 * operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1857 * the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1858 * handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1859 * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
1860 * be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
1861 * opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
1862 */
1863 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1864 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1865 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1866 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1867 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1868 IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE = BIT(4),
1869 IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW = BIT(5),
1870 IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC = BIT(6),
1871 };
1872
1873
1874 /**
1875 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1876 *
1877 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1878 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1879 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1880 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1881 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1882 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1883 * mac80211.
1884 */
1885
1886 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1887 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1888 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1889 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1890 };
1891
1892 /**
1893 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1894 * @assoc: association status
1895 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1896 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1897 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1898 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1899 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1900 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1901 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1902 * P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1903 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1904 * Figure 9-1001k
1905 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1906 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1907 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1908 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1909 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1910 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1911 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1912 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1913 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1914 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1915 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1916 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1917 * your driver/device needs to do.
1918 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1919 * (station mode only)
1920 */
1921 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1922 /* association related data */
1923 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1924 bool ibss_creator;
1925 bool ps;
1926 u16 aid;
1927 u16 eml_cap;
1928 u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1929 u16 mld_capa_op;
1930
1931 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1932 int arp_addr_cnt;
1933 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1934 size_t ssid_len;
1935 bool s1g;
1936 bool idle;
1937 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1938 };
1939
1940 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1941
1942 /**
1943 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1944 *
1945 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1946 * this TID is not included.
1947 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1948 * TID is not included.
1949 * @valid: info is valid or not.
1950 */
1951 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1952 u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1953 u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1954 bool valid;
1955 };
1956
1957 /**
1958 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1959 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1960 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1961 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1962 */
1963 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1964 NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1965 NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1966 NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1967 };
1968
1969 /**
1970 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1971 *
1972 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1973 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1974 *
1975 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1976 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1977 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1978 * or the BSS we're associated to
1979 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1980 * indexed by link ID
1981 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1982 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1983 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1984 * API calls meant for that purpose.
1985 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1986 * due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1987 * 0 for non-MLO.
1988 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1989 * suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
1990 * future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
1991 * 0 for non-MLO.
1992 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1993 * see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1994 * @addr: address of this interface
1995 * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
1996 * passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
1997 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1998 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1999 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
2000 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
2001 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
2002 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
2003 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
2004 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2005 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2006 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2007 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2008 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2009 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2010 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2011 * restrictions.
2012 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2013 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2014 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2015 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2016 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2017 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2018 * interface.
2019 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2020 * for this interface.
2021 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2022 * sizeof(void \*).
2023 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2024 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2025 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2026 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
2027 */
2028 struct ieee80211_vif {
2029 enum nl80211_iftype type;
2030 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2031 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2032 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2033 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2034 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2035 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2036 bool addr_valid;
2037 bool p2p;
2038
2039 u8 cab_queue;
2040 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2041
2042 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2043
2044 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2045 u32 driver_flags;
2046 u32 offload_flags;
2047
2048 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2049 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2050 #endif
2051
2052 bool probe_req_reg;
2053 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2054
2055 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
2056
2057 /* must be last */
2058 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2059 };
2060
2061 /**
2062 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2063 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2064 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2065 */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2066 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2067 {
2068 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2069 }
2070
2071 /**
2072 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2073 * @vif: the vif
2074 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2075 */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2076 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2077 {
2078 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2079 return vif->valid_links != 0;
2080 }
2081
2082 /**
2083 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2084 * @vif: the vif
2085 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2086 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2087 * the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2088 */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2089 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2090 unsigned int link_id)
2091 {
2092 if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2093 return link_id == 0;
2094 return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2095 }
2096
2097 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
2098 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
2099 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2100 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2101 (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2102
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2103 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2104 {
2105 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2106 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2107 #endif
2108 return false;
2109 }
2110
2111 /**
2112 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2113 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2114 *
2115 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2116 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2117 *
2118 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2119 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2120 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2121 */
2122 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2123
2124 /**
2125 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2126 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2127 *
2128 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2129 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2130 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2131 *
2132 * Return: pointer to the wdev
2133 */
2134 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2135
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2136 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2137 {
2138 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2139 }
2140
2141 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
2142 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2143 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2144
2145 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
2146 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2147 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2148
2149 /**
2150 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2151 *
2152 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2153 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2154 *
2155 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2156 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2157 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2158 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2159 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2160 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2161 * generation in software.
2162 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2163 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2164 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2165 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2166 * (MFP) to be done in software.
2167 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2168 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2169 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2170 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2171 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2172 * MIC.
2173 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2174 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2175 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2176 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2177 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2178 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2179 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2180 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2181 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2182 * only for management frames (MFP).
2183 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2184 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2185 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2186 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2187 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2188 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2189 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2190 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2191 * for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2192 * number generation only
2193 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2194 * (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2195 */
2196 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2197 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2198 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2199 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2200 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2201 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2202 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2203 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2204 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2205 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2206 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2207 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2208 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(11),
2209 };
2210
2211 /**
2212 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2213 *
2214 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2215 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2216 *
2217 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2218 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2219 * encrypted in hardware.
2220 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2221 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2222 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2223 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2224 * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
2225 * @keylen: key material length
2226 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2227 * data block:
2228 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2229 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2230 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2231 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2232 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2233 * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
2234 */
2235 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2236 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2237 u32 cipher;
2238 u8 icv_len;
2239 u8 iv_len;
2240 u8 hw_key_idx;
2241 s8 keyidx;
2242 u16 flags;
2243 s8 link_id;
2244 u8 keylen;
2245 u8 key[];
2246 };
2247
2248 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2249
2250 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2251 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2252
2253 /**
2254 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2255 *
2256 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2257 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2258 * reverse order than in packet)
2259 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2260 * reverse order than in packet)
2261 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2262 * reverse order than in packet)
2263 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2264 * reverse order than in packet)
2265 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2266 */
2267 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2268 union {
2269 struct {
2270 u32 iv32;
2271 u16 iv16;
2272 } tkip;
2273 struct {
2274 u8 pn[6];
2275 } ccmp;
2276 struct {
2277 u8 pn[6];
2278 } aes_cmac;
2279 struct {
2280 u8 pn[6];
2281 } aes_gmac;
2282 struct {
2283 u8 pn[6];
2284 } gcmp;
2285 struct {
2286 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2287 u8 seq_len;
2288 } hw;
2289 };
2290 };
2291
2292 /**
2293 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2294 *
2295 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2296 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2297 *
2298 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2299 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2300 */
2301 enum set_key_cmd {
2302 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2303 };
2304
2305 /**
2306 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2307 *
2308 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2309 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2310 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2311 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2312 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2313 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2314 */
2315 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2316 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2317 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2318 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2319 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2320 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2321 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2322 };
2323
2324 /**
2325 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2326 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2327 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2328 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2329 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2330 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2331 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2332 *
2333 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2334 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2335 */
2336 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2337 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2338 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2339 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2340 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2341 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2342 };
2343
2344 #define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320
2345
2346 /**
2347 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2348 *
2349 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2350 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2351 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2352 */
2353 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2354 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2355 struct {
2356 s8 idx;
2357 u8 count;
2358 u8 count_cts;
2359 u8 count_rts;
2360 u16 flags;
2361 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2362 };
2363
2364 /**
2365 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2366 *
2367 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2368 *
2369 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2370 * to the STA.
2371 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2372 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2373 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2374 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2375 * per peer TPC.
2376 */
2377 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2378 s16 power;
2379 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2380 };
2381
2382 /**
2383 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2384 *
2385 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2386 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2387 *
2388 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2389 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2390 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2391 *
2392 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2393 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2394 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2395 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2396 *
2397 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2398 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2399 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2400 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2401 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2402 */
2403 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2404 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2405
2406 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2407 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2408 };
2409
2410 /**
2411 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2412 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2413 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2414 *
2415 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2416 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2417 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2418 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2419 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2420 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2421 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2422 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2423 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2424 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2425 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2426 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2427 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2428 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2429 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2430 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2431 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2432 * the station moves to associated state.
2433 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2434 *
2435 */
2436 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2437 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2438
2439 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2440 u8 link_id;
2441 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2442
2443 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2444 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2445 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2446 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2447 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2448 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2449
2450 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2451
2452 u8 rx_nss;
2453 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2454 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2455 };
2456
2457 /**
2458 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2459 *
2460 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2461 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2462 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2463 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2464 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2465 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2466 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2467 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2468 *
2469 * @addr: MAC address
2470 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2471 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2472 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2473 * Can be modified by driver.
2474 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2475 * otherwise always false)
2476 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2477 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2478 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2479 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2480 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2481 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2482 * @rates: rate control selection table
2483 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2484 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2485 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2486 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2487 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2488 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2489 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2490 * unlimited.
2491 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2492 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2493 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2494 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2495 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2496 * is used for non-data frames
2497 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2498 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2499 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2500 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2501 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2502 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2503 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2504 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2505 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2506 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2507 * by the AP.
2508 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2509 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2510 */
2511 struct ieee80211_sta {
2512 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2513 u16 aid;
2514 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2515 bool wme;
2516 u8 uapsd_queues;
2517 u8 max_sp;
2518 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2519 bool tdls;
2520 bool tdls_initiator;
2521 bool mfp;
2522 bool mlo;
2523 bool spp_amsdu;
2524 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2525
2526 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2527
2528 bool support_p2p_ps;
2529
2530 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2531
2532 u16 valid_links;
2533 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2534 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2535
2536 /* must be last */
2537 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2538 };
2539
2540 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2541 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2542 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2543 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2544 {
2545 return true;
2546 }
2547 #endif
2548
2549 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2550 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2551 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2552
2553 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2554 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2555 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2556
2557 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2558 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2559 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2560 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2561 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2562
2563 /**
2564 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2565 *
2566 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2567 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2568 *
2569 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2570 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2571 */
2572 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2573 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2574 };
2575
2576 /**
2577 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2578 *
2579 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2580 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2581 */
2582 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2583 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2584 };
2585
2586 /**
2587 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2588 *
2589 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2590 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2591 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2592 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2593 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2594 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2595 *
2596 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2597 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2598 */
2599 struct ieee80211_txq {
2600 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2601 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2602 u8 tid;
2603 u8 ac;
2604
2605 /* must be last */
2606 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2607 };
2608
2609 /**
2610 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2611 *
2612 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2613 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2614 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2615 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2616 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2617 *
2618 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2619 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2620 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2621 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2622 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2623 * algorithm.
2624 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2625 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2626 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2627 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2628 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2629 * CCK frames.
2630 *
2631 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2632 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2633 * the FCS at the end.
2634 *
2635 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2636 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2637 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2638 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2639 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2640 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2641 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2642 *
2643 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2644 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2645 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2646 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2647 *
2648 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2649 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2650 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2651 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2652 *
2653 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2654 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2655 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2656 *
2657 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2658 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2659 *
2660 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2661 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2662 *
2663 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2664 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2665 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2666 *
2667 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2668 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2669 *
2670 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2671 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2672 *
2673 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2674 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2675 * the stack.
2676 *
2677 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2678 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2679 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2680 *
2681 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2682 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2683 * dtim_period).
2684 *
2685 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2686 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2687 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2688 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2689 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2690 * only in that case.
2691 *
2692 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2693 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2694 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2695 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2696 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2697 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2698 *
2699 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2700 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2701 * software.
2702 *
2703 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2704 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2705 * active interfaces.
2706 *
2707 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2708 * of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2709 * This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2710 * channels.
2711 *
2712 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2713 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2714 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2715 *
2716 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2717 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2718 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2719 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2720 * supported cipher suites.
2721 *
2722 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2723 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2724 * for frames.
2725 *
2726 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2727 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2728 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2729 * control for more details.
2730 *
2731 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2732 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2733 *
2734 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2735 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2736 * is supported.
2737 *
2738 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2739 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2740 *
2741 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2742 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2743 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2744 *
2745 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2746 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2747 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2748 * CSA frame.
2749 *
2750 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2751 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2752 *
2753 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2754 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2755 *
2756 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2757 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2758 *
2759 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2760 * within A-MPDU.
2761 *
2762 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2763 * for sent beacons.
2764 *
2765 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2766 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2767 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2768 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2769 *
2770 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2771 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2772 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2773 * timeout.
2774 *
2775 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2776 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2777 *
2778 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2779 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2780 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2781 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2782 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2783 *
2784 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2785 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2786 *
2787 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2788 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2789 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2790 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2791 *
2792 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2793 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2794 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2795 *
2796 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2797 * TDLS links.
2798 *
2799 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2800 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2801 *
2802 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2803 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2804 *
2805 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2806 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2807 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2808 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2809 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2810 *
2811 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2812 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2813 * TXQs to start with.
2814 *
2815 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2816 * length in tx status information
2817 *
2818 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2819 *
2820 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2821 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2822 *
2823 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2824 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2825 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2826 *
2827 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2828 * offload
2829 *
2830 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2831 * offload
2832 *
2833 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2834 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2835 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2836 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2837 * the stack.
2838 *
2839 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2840 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2841 *
2842 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2843 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2844 *
2845 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2846 * and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2847 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ: HW requires disabling puncturing in
2848 * EHT in 5 GHz and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2849 *
2850 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2851 * no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2852 * implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2853 * link is switching.
2854 *
2855 * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
2856 * but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
2857 * HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
2858 * testing.
2859 *
2860 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2861 */
2862 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2863 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2864 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2865 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2866 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2867 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2868 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2869 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2870 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2871 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2872 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2873 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2874 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2875 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2876 IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
2877 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2878 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2879 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2880 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2881 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2882 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2883 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2884 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2885 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2886 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2887 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2888 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2889 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2890 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2891 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2892 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2893 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2894 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2895 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2896 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2897 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2898 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2899 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2900 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2901 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2902 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2903 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2904 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2905 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2906 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2907 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2908 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2909 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2910 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2911 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2912 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2913 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2914 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2915 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2916 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2917 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2918 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ,
2919 IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2920 IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
2921
2922 /* keep last, obviously */
2923 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2924 };
2925
2926 /**
2927 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2928 *
2929 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2930 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2931 *
2932 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2933 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2934 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2935 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2936 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2937 *
2938 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2939 *
2940 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2941 * along with this structure.
2942 *
2943 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2944 *
2945 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2946 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2947 *
2948 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2949 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2950 *
2951 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2952 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2953 *
2954 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2955 * that HW supports
2956 *
2957 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2958 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2959 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2960 *
2961 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2962 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2963 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2964 *
2965 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2966 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2967 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2968 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2969 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2970 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2971 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2972 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2973 *
2974 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2975 * can handle.
2976 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2977 * the hw can report back.
2978 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2979 *
2980 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2981 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2982 * aggregation.
2983 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2984 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2985 * it shouldn't be set.
2986 *
2987 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2988 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2989 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2990 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2991 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2992 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2993 *
2994 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2995 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2996 *
2997 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2998 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2999 *
3000 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
3001 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
3002 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
3003 * adding _BW is supported today.
3004 *
3005 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
3006 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
3007 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
3008 *
3009 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
3010 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
3011 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
3012 * device_timestamp.
3013 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3014 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3015 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3016 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3017 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3018 *
3019 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3020 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3021 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3022 *
3023 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3024 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3025 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3026 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3027 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3028 * neither enabled.
3029 *
3030 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3031 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3032 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3033 *
3034 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3035 * device.
3036 *
3037 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3038 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3039 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3040 *
3041 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3042 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3043 *
3044 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3045 *
3046 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3047 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3048 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3049 *
3050 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3051 */
3052 struct ieee80211_hw {
3053 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3054 struct wiphy *wiphy;
3055 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3056 void *priv;
3057 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3058 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3059 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3060 int vif_data_size;
3061 int sta_data_size;
3062 int chanctx_data_size;
3063 int txq_data_size;
3064 u16 queues;
3065 u16 max_listen_interval;
3066 s8 max_signal;
3067 u8 max_rates;
3068 u8 max_report_rates;
3069 u8 max_rate_tries;
3070 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3071 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3072 u8 max_tx_fragments;
3073 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3074 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3075 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3076 struct {
3077 int units_pos;
3078 s16 accuracy;
3079 } radiotap_timestamp;
3080 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3081 u8 uapsd_queues;
3082 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3083 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3084 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3085 u8 weight_multiplier;
3086 u32 max_mtu;
3087 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3088 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3089 };
3090
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3091 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3092 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3093 {
3094 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3095 }
3096 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3097
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3098 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3099 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3100 {
3101 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3102 }
3103 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3104
3105 /**
3106 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3107 *
3108 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3109 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3110 */
3111 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3112 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3113
3114 /* Keep last */
3115 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3116 };
3117
3118 /**
3119 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3120 *
3121 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3122 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3123 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3124 * @status: channel-switch response status
3125 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3126 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3127 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3128 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3129 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3130 */
3131 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3132 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3133 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3134 u8 action_code;
3135 u32 status;
3136 u32 timestamp;
3137 u16 switch_time;
3138 u16 switch_timeout;
3139 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3140 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3141 };
3142
3143 /**
3144 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3145 *
3146 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3147 *
3148 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3149 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3150 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3151 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3152 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3153 *
3154 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3155 */
3156 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3157
3158 /**
3159 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3160 *
3161 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3162 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3163 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3164 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3165 {
3166 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3167 }
3168
3169 /**
3170 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3171 *
3172 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3173 * @addr: the address to set
3174 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3175 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3176 {
3177 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3178 }
3179
3180 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3181 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3182 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3183 {
3184 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3185 return NULL;
3186 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3187 }
3188
3189 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3190 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3191 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3192 {
3193 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3194 return NULL;
3195 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3196 }
3197
3198 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3199 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3200 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3201 {
3202 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3203 return NULL;
3204 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3205 }
3206
3207 /**
3208 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3209 * @hw: the hardware
3210 * @skb: the skb
3211 *
3212 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3213 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3214 */
3215 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3216
3217 /**
3218 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3219 * @hw: the hardware
3220 * @skbs: the skbs
3221 *
3222 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3223 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3224 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3225 * relevant locks to use it.
3226 */
3227 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3228 struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3229
3230 /**
3231 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3232 *
3233 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3234 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3235 *
3236 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3237 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3238 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3239 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3240 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3241 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3242 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3243 *
3244 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3245 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3246 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3247 *
3248 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3249 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3250 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3251 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3252 *
3253 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3254 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3255 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3256 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3257 *
3258 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3259 *
3260 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3261 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3262 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3263 * based on the receive flags.
3264 *
3265 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3266 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3267 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3268 * keys.
3269 *
3270 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3271 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3272 * handler.
3273 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3274 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3275 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3276 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3277 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3278 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3279 *
3280 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3281 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3282 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3283 *
3284 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3285 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3286 * requirements:
3287 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3288 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3289 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3290 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3291 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3292 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3293 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3294 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3295 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3296 */
3297
3298 /**
3299 * DOC: Powersave support
3300 *
3301 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3302 *
3303 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3304 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3305 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3306 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3307 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3308 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3309 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3310 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3311 *
3312 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3313 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3314 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3315 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3316 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3317 *
3318 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3319 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3320 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3321 *
3322 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3323 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3324 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3325 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3326 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3327 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3328 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3329 *
3330 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3331 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3332 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3333 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3334 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3335 * periods.
3336 *
3337 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3338 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3339 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3340 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3341 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3342 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3343 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3344 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3345 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3346 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3347 *
3348 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3349 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3350 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3351 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3352 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3353 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3354 *
3355 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3356 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3357 */
3358
3359 /**
3360 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3361 *
3362 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3363 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3364 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3365 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3366 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3367 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3368 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3369 *
3370 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3371 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3372 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3373 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3374 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3375 *
3376 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3377 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3378 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3379 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3380 *
3381 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3382 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3383 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3384 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3385 *
3386 * - a list of information element IDs
3387 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3388 *
3389 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3390 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3391 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3392 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3393 * vendor information elements.
3394 *
3395 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3396 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3397 *
3398 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3399 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3400 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3401 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3402 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3403 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3404 *
3405 *
3406 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3407 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3408 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3409 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3410 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3411 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3412 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3413 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3414 *
3415 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3416 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3417 * signal strength threshold checking.
3418 */
3419
3420 /**
3421 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3422 *
3423 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3424 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3425 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3426 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3427 *
3428 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3429 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3430 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3431 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3432 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3433 * hardware flags.
3434 *
3435 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3436 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3437 * turned off otherwise.
3438 *
3439 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3440 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3441 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3442 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3443 */
3444
3445 /**
3446 * DOC: Frame filtering
3447 *
3448 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3449 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3450 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3451 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3452 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3453 *
3454 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3455 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3456 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3457 *
3458 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3459 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3460 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3461 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3462 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3463 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3464 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3465 *
3466 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3467 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3468 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3469 * or dropped.
3470 *
3471 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3472 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3473 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3474 * the flag, but not clear it.
3475 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3476 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3477 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3478 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3479 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3480 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3481 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3482 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3483 */
3484
3485 /**
3486 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3487 *
3488 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3489 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3490 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3491 *
3492 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3493 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3494 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3495 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3496 * the driver code.
3497 *
3498 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3499 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3500 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3501 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3502 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3503 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3504 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3505 *
3506 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3507 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3508 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3509 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3510 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3511 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3512 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3513 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3514 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3515 * @sta_notify callback.
3516 *
3517 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3518 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3519 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3520 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3521 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3522 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3523 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3524 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3525 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3526 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3527 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3528 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3529 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3530 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3531 *
3532 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3533 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3534 *
3535 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3536 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3537 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3538 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3539 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3540 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3541 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3542 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3543 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3544 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3545 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3546 *
3547 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3548 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3549 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3550 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3551 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3552 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3553 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3554 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3555 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3556 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3557 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3558 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3559 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3560 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3561 *
3562 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3563 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3564 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3565 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3566 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3567 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3568 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3569 *
3570 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3571 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3572 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3573 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3574 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3575 *
3576 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3577 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3578 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3579 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3580 */
3581
3582 /**
3583 * DOC: HW queue control
3584 *
3585 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3586 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3587 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3588 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3589 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3590 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3591 *
3592 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3593 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3594 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3595 *
3596 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3597 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3598 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3599 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3600 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3601 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3602 * the hardware queue.
3603 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3604 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3605 *
3606 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3607 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3608 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3609 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3610 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3611 *
3612 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3613 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3614 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3615 * off-channel queue: 9
3616 *
3617 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3618 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3619 *
3620 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3621 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3622 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3623 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3624 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3625 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3626 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3627 *
3628 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3629 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3630 *
3631 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3632 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3633 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3634 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3635 */
3636
3637 /**
3638 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3639 *
3640 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3641 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3642 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3643 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3644 *
3645 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3646 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3647 * multicast address.
3648 *
3649 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3650 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3651 *
3652 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3653 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3654 *
3655 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3656 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3657 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3658 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3659 * honour this flag if possible.
3660 *
3661 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3662 * station
3663 *
3664 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3665 *
3666 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3667 *
3668 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3669 *
3670 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3671 */
3672 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3673 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3674 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3675 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3676 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3677 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3678 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3679 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3680 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3681 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3682 };
3683
3684 /**
3685 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3686 *
3687 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3688 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3689 *
3690 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3691 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3692 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3693 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3694 *
3695 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3696 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3697 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3698 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3699 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3700 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3701 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3702 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3703 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3704 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3705 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3706 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3707 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3708 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3709 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3710 * session is gone and removes the station.
3711 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3712 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3713 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3714 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3715 */
3716 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3717 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3718 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3719 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3720 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3721 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3722 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3723 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3724 };
3725
3726 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3727 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3728
3729 /**
3730 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3731 *
3732 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3733 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3734 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3735 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3736 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3737 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3738 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3739 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3740 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3741 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3742 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3743 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3744 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3745 */
3746 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3747 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3748 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3749 u16 tid;
3750 u16 ssn;
3751 u16 buf_size;
3752 bool amsdu;
3753 u16 timeout;
3754 };
3755
3756 /**
3757 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3758 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3759 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3760 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3761 */
3762 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3763 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3764 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3765 };
3766
3767 /**
3768 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3769 *
3770 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3771 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3772 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3773 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3774 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3775 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3776 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3777 * the peer.
3778 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3779 * by the peer
3780 */
3781 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3782 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3783 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3784 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3785 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3786 };
3787
3788 /**
3789 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3790 *
3791 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3792 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3793 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3794 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3795 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3796 *
3797 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3798 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3799 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3800 */
3801 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3802 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3803 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3804 };
3805
3806 /**
3807 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3808 *
3809 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3810 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3811 *
3812 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3813 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3814 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3815 * of wowlan configuration)
3816 */
3817 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3818 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3819 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3820 };
3821
3822 /**
3823 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3824 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3825 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3826 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3827 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3828 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3829 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3830 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3831 * while just having been associated
3832 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3833 * 0 for a non-MLO connection.
3834 */
3835 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3836 u16 duration;
3837 u16 subtype;
3838 u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3839 int link_id;
3840 };
3841
3842 /**
3843 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3844 *
3845 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3846 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3847 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3848 *
3849 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3850 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3851 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3852 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3853 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3854 * Must be atomic.
3855 *
3856 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3857 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3858 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3859 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3860 * or zero.
3861 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3862 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3863 * is added.
3864 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3865 *
3866 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3867 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3868 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3869 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3870 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3871 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3872 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3873 *
3874 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3875 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3876 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3877 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3878 * reconfigured at resume time.
3879 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3880 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3881 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3882 * must return 1 from this function.
3883 *
3884 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3885 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3886 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3887 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3888 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3889 *
3890 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3891 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3892 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3893 * in suspend().
3894 *
3895 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3896 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3897 * and @stop must be implemented.
3898 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3899 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3900 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3901 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3902 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3903 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3904 *
3905 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3906 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3907 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3908 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3909 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3910 *
3911 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3912 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3913 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3914 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3915 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3916 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3917 * MAC address of the device going away.
3918 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3919 *
3920 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3921 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3922 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3923 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3924 *
3925 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3926 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3927 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3928 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3929 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3930 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3931 * can sleep.
3932 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3933 * are not implemented.
3934 *
3935 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3936 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3937 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3938 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3939 * The callback can sleep.
3940 *
3941 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3942 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3943 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3944 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3945 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3946 * non-MLO connections.
3947 * The callback can sleep.
3948 *
3949 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3950 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3951 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3952 *
3953 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3954 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3955 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3956 *
3957 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3958 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3959 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3960 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3961 * which flags are changed.
3962 * This callback can sleep.
3963 *
3964 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3965 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3966 *
3967 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3968 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3969 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3970 * is enabled.
3971 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3972 * The callback can sleep.
3973 *
3974 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3975 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3976 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3977 * The callback must be atomic.
3978 *
3979 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3980 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3981 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3982 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3983 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3984 *
3985 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3986 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3987 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3988 *
3989 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3990 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3991 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3992 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3993 * that power save is disabled.
3994 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3995 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3996 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3997 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3998 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3999 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
4000 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
4001 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
4002 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
4003 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
4004 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
4005 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
4006 * The callback can sleep.
4007 *
4008 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
4009 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
4010 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
4011 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
4012 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4013 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4014 * The callback can sleep.
4015 *
4016 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4017 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
4018 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4019 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4020 *
4021 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4022 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4023 *
4024 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4025 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4026 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4027 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4028 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4029 *
4030 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4031 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4032 * this notification.
4033 * The callback can sleep.
4034 *
4035 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4036 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
4037 * The callback can sleep.
4038 *
4039 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4040 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4041 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4042 * The callback must be atomic.
4043 *
4044 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4045 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4046 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4047 * should be set as well.
4048 * The callback can sleep.
4049 *
4050 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4051 * The callback can sleep.
4052 *
4053 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4054 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4055 *
4056 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4057 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4058 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4059 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4060 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4061 * This callback can sleep.
4062 *
4063 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4064 * directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4065 * CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4066 *
4067 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4068 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4069 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4070 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4071 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4072 *
4073 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4074 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4075 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4076 * callback can sleep.
4077 *
4078 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4079 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4080 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4081 * callback can sleep.
4082 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4083 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4084 *
4085 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4086 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4087 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4088 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4089 *
4090 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4091 * power for the station.
4092 * This callback can sleep.
4093 *
4094 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4095 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4096 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4097 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4098 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4099 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4100 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4101 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4102 * The callback can sleep.
4103 *
4104 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4105 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4106 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4107 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4108 * in @sta_state.
4109 * The callback can sleep.
4110 *
4111 * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4112 * be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4113 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4114 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4115 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4116 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4117 * Must be atomic.
4118 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4119 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4120 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4121 *
4122 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4123 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4124 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4125 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4126 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4127 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4128 * The callback can sleep.
4129 *
4130 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4131 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4132 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
4133 * The callback can sleep.
4134 *
4135 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4136 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4137 * required function.
4138 * The callback can sleep.
4139 *
4140 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4141 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4142 * required function.
4143 * The callback can sleep.
4144 *
4145 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4146 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4147 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4148 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4149 * The callback can sleep.
4150 *
4151 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4152 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4153 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4154 * TSF synchronization.
4155 * The callback can sleep.
4156 *
4157 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4158 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4159 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4160 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4161 * The callback can sleep.
4162 *
4163 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4164 *
4165 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4166 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4167 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4168 * The callback can sleep.
4169 *
4170 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4171 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4172 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4173 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4174 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4175 *
4176 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4177 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4178 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4179 *
4180 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4181 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4182 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4183 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4184 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4185 * Note that vif can be NULL.
4186 * The callback can sleep.
4187 *
4188 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4189 * the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4190 * The callback can sleep.
4191 *
4192 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4193 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4194 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4195 * completion of the channel switch.
4196 *
4197 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4198 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4199 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4200 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4201 *
4202 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4203 *
4204 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4205 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4206 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4207 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4208 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4209 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4210 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4211 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4212 * must be accepted in this case.
4213 * This callback may sleep.
4214 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4215 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4216 *
4217 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4218 *
4219 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4220 *
4221 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4222 * queues before entering power save.
4223 *
4224 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4225 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4226 * The callback can sleep.
4227 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4228 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4229 * The callback must be atomic.
4230 *
4231 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4232 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4233 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4234 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4235 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4236 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4237 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4238 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4239 * more-data bit must always be set.
4240 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4241 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4242 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4243 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4244 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4245 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4246 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4247 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4248 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4249 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4250 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4251 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4252 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4253 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4254 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4255 * This callback must be atomic.
4256 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4257 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4258 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4259 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4260 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4261 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4262 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4263 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4264 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4265 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4266 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4267 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4268 * This callback must be atomic.
4269 *
4270 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4271 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4272 * expected to return a static value.
4273 *
4274 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4275 *
4276 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4277 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4278 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4279 * expected to return a static value.
4280 *
4281 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4282 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4283 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4284 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4285 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4286 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4287 * management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4288 * to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4289 * able to synchronize with the GO.
4290 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4291 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4292 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4293 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4294 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4295 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4296 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4297 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4298 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4299 *
4300 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4301 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4302 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4303 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4304 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4305 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4306 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4307 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4308 *
4309 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4310 * This callback may sleep.
4311 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4312 * This callback may sleep.
4313 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4314 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4315 * channel context with different settings
4316 * This callback may sleep.
4317 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4318 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4319 * This callback may sleep.
4320 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4321 * unbound from vif.
4322 * This callback may sleep.
4323 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4324 * another, as specified in the list of
4325 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4326 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4327 * This callback may sleep.
4328 *
4329 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4330 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4331 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4332 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4333 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4334 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4335 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4336 *
4337 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4338 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4339 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4340 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4341 * This callback may sleep.
4342 *
4343 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4344 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4345 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4346 *
4347 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4348 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4349 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4350 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4351 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4352 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4353 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4354 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4355 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4356 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4357 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4358 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4359 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4360 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4361 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4362 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4363 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4364 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4365 * when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4366 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4367 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4368 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4369 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4370 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4371 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4372 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4373 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4374 *
4375 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4376 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4377 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4378 *
4379 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4380 * and hardware limits.
4381 *
4382 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4383 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4384 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4385 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4386 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4387 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4388 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4389 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4390 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4391 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4392 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4393 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4394 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4395 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4396 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4397 * the function call.
4398 *
4399 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4400 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4401 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4402 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4403 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4404 *
4405 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4406 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4407 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4408 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4409 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4410 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4411 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4412 * changed parameters.
4413 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4414 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4415 * this call.
4416 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4417 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4418 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4419 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4420 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4421 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4422 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4423 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4424 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4425 *
4426 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4427 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4428 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4429 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4430 * This callback may sleep.
4431 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4432 * This callback may sleep.
4433 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4434 * 4-address mode
4435 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4436 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4437 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4438 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4439 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4440 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4441 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4442 * twt structure.
4443 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4444 * from the peer.
4445 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4446 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4447 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4448 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4449 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4450 * radar channel.
4451 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4452 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4453 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4454 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4455 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4456 * supported by the driver.
4457 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4458 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4459 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4460 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4461 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4462 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4463 * This callback can sleep.
4464 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4465 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4466 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4467 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4468 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4469 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4470 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4471 * that.
4472 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4473 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4474 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4475 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4476 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4477 * if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4478 * If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4479 * modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4480 * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4481 * drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4482 * the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4483 * interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4484 * implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4485 * &enum nl80211_iftype.
4486 */
4487 struct ieee80211_ops {
4488 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4489 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4490 struct sk_buff *skb);
4491 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4492 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4493 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4494 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4495 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4496 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4497 #endif
4498 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4499 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4500 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4501 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4502 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4503 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4504 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4505 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4506 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4507 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4508 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4509 u64 changed);
4510 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4512 u64 changed);
4513 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4514 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4515 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4516 u64 changed);
4517
4518 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4519 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4520 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4521 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4522
4523 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4524 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4525 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4526 unsigned int changed_flags,
4527 unsigned int *total_flags,
4528 u64 multicast);
4529 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4530 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4531 unsigned int filter_flags,
4532 unsigned int changed_flags);
4533 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4534 bool set);
4535 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4536 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4537 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4538 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4539 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4540 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4541 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4542 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4543 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4545 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4546 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4548 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4549 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4550 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4551 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4552 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4553 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4554 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4555 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4556 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4557 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4558 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4559 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4560 const u8 *mac_addr);
4561 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4562 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4563 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4565 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4566 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4567 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4568 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4569 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4570 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4572 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4573 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4574 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4575 void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4576 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4577 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4579 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4580 struct dentry *dir);
4581 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4582 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4583 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4584 struct dentry *dir);
4585 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4586 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4587 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4588 struct dentry *dir);
4589 #endif
4590 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4591 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4592 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4593 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4594 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4595 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4597 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4598 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4599 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4600 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4601 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4602 void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4603 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4604 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4605 u32 changed);
4606 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4607 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4608 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4609 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4610 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4611 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4612 struct station_info *sinfo);
4613 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4614 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4615 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4616 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4617 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4618 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4619 u64 tsf);
4620 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4621 s64 offset);
4622 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4623 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4624
4625 /**
4626 * @ampdu_action:
4627 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4628 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4629 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4630 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4631 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4632 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4633 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4634 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4635 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4636 *
4637 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4638 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4639 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4640 *
4641 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4642 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4643 *
4644 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4645 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4646 * - ``TX: 81``
4647 *
4648 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4649 *
4650 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4651 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4652 * if the session can start immediately.
4653 *
4654 * The callback can sleep.
4655 */
4656 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4657 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4658 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4659 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4660 struct survey_info *survey);
4661 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4662 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4663 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4664 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4665 void *data, int len);
4666 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4667 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4668 void *data, int len);
4669 #endif
4670 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4671 u32 queues, bool drop);
4672 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4673 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4674 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4675 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4676 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4677 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4678 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4679
4680 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4681 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4682 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4683 int duration,
4684 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4685 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4686 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4687 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4688 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4689 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4690 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4691 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4692 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4693 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4694 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4695 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4696
4697 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4698 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4699 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4700 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4701 bool more_data);
4702 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4703 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4704 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4705 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4706 bool more_data);
4707
4708 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4709 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4710 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4711 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4712 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4713 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4714 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4715 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4716
4717 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4718 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4719 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4720 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4721 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4722 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4723
4724 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4725 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4726 unsigned int link_id);
4727
4728 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4729 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4730 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4731 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4732 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4733 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4734 u32 changed);
4735 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4736 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4737 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4738 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4739 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4740 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4741 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4742 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4743 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4744 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4745 int n_vifs,
4746 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4747
4748 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4749 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4750
4751 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4752 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4753 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4754 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4755 #endif
4756 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4757 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4758 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4759 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4760 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4761 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4762
4763 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4764 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4765 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4766 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4767 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4768 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4769 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4770 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4771 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4772
4773 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4774 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4775 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4776 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4777 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4778 unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4779
4780 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4781 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4782 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4783 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4784 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4785 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4786 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4787 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4788 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4789 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4790 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4791
4792 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4793 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4794 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4795
4796 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4797 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4798 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4799 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4800 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4801 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4802 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4803 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4804 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4805 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4806 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4807 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4808 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4809 u8 instance_id);
4810 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4811 struct sk_buff *head,
4812 struct sk_buff *skb);
4813 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4814 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4815 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4816 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4817 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4818 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4819 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4820 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4821 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4822 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4823 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4824 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4825 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4826 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4827 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4828 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4829 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4830 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4831 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4832 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4833 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4834 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4835 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4836 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4837 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4838 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4839 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4840 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4841 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4842 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4843 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4844 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4845 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4846 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4847 struct net_device_path *path);
4848 bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4849 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4850 u16 active_links);
4851 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4852 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4853 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4854 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4855 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4856 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4857 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4858 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4859 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4860 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4861 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4862 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4863 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4864 struct net_device *dev,
4865 enum tc_setup_type type,
4866 void *type_data);
4867 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4868 (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4869 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4870 void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4871 enum nl80211_iftype type);
4872 };
4873
4874 /**
4875 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4876 *
4877 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4878 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4879 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4880 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4881 * @priv_data_len.
4882 *
4883 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4884 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4885 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4886 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4887 *
4888 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4889 */
4890 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4891 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4892 const char *requested_name);
4893
4894 /**
4895 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4896 *
4897 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4898 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4899 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4900 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4901 * @priv_data_len.
4902 *
4903 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4904 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4905 *
4906 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4907 */
4908 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4909 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4910 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4911 {
4912 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4913 }
4914
4915 /**
4916 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4917 *
4918 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4919 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4920 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4921 *
4922 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4923 *
4924 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4925 */
4926 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4927
4928 /**
4929 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4930 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4931 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4932 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4933 */
4934 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4935 int throughput;
4936 int blink_time;
4937 };
4938
4939 /**
4940 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4941 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4942 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4943 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4944 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4945 */
4946 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4947 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4948 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4949 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4950 };
4951
4952 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4953 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4954 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4955 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4956 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4957 const char *
4958 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4959 unsigned int flags,
4960 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4961 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4962 #endif
4963 /**
4964 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4965 *
4966 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4967 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4968 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4969 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4970 *
4971 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4972 *
4973 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4974 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4975 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4976 {
4977 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4978 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4979 #else
4980 return NULL;
4981 #endif
4982 }
4983
4984 /**
4985 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4986 *
4987 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4988 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4989 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4990 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4991 *
4992 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4993 *
4994 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4995 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4996 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4997 {
4998 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4999 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
5000 #else
5001 return NULL;
5002 #endif
5003 }
5004
5005 /**
5006 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
5007 *
5008 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5009 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5010 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5011 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5012 *
5013 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5014 *
5015 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5016 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5017 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5018 {
5019 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5020 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5021 #else
5022 return NULL;
5023 #endif
5024 }
5025
5026 /**
5027 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5028 *
5029 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5030 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5031 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5032 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5033 *
5034 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5035 *
5036 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5037 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5038 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5039 {
5040 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5041 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5042 #else
5043 return NULL;
5044 #endif
5045 }
5046
5047 /**
5048 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5049 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5050 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5051 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5052 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5053 *
5054 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5055 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5056 *
5057 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5058 */
5059 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5060 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5061 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5062 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5063 {
5064 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5065 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5066 blink_table_len);
5067 #else
5068 return NULL;
5069 #endif
5070 }
5071
5072 /**
5073 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5074 *
5075 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5076 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5077 *
5078 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5079 */
5080 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5081
5082 /**
5083 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5084 *
5085 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5086 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5087 * before calling this function.
5088 *
5089 * @hw: the hardware to free
5090 */
5091 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5092
5093 /**
5094 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5095 *
5096 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5097 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5098 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5099 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5100 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5101 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5102 *
5103 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5104 */
5105 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5106
5107 /**
5108 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5109 *
5110 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5111 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5112 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5113 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5114 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5115 *
5116 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5117 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5118 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5119 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5120 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5121 *
5122 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5123 *
5124 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5125 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5126 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5127 * @list: the destination list
5128 */
5129 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5130 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5131
5132 /**
5133 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5134 *
5135 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5136 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5137 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5138 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5139 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5140 *
5141 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5142 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5143 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5144 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5145 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5146 *
5147 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5148 *
5149 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5150 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5151 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5152 * @napi: the NAPI context
5153 */
5154 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5155 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5156
5157 /**
5158 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5159 *
5160 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5161 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5162 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5163 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5164 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5165 *
5166 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5167 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5168 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5169 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5170 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5171 *
5172 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5173 *
5174 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5175 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5176 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5177 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5178 {
5179 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5180 }
5181
5182 /**
5183 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5184 *
5185 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5186 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5187 *
5188 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5189 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5190 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5191 *
5192 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5193 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5194 */
5195 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5196
5197 /**
5198 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5199 *
5200 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5201 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5202 *
5203 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5204 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5205 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5206 *
5207 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5208 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5209 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5210 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5211 struct sk_buff *skb)
5212 {
5213 local_bh_disable();
5214 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5215 local_bh_enable();
5216 }
5217
5218 /**
5219 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5220 *
5221 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5222 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5223 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5224 *
5225 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5226 *
5227 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5228 * each other.
5229 *
5230 * @sta: currently connected sta
5231 * @start: start or stop PS
5232 *
5233 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5234 */
5235 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5236
5237 /**
5238 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5239 * (in process context)
5240 *
5241 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5242 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5243 * applies.
5244 *
5245 * @sta: currently connected sta
5246 * @start: start or stop PS
5247 *
5248 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5249 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5250 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5251 bool start)
5252 {
5253 int ret;
5254
5255 local_bh_disable();
5256 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5257 local_bh_enable();
5258
5259 return ret;
5260 }
5261
5262 /**
5263 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5264 * @sta: currently connected station
5265 *
5266 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5267 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5268 * connected station was received.
5269 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5270 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5271 * be serialized.
5272 */
5273 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5274
5275 /**
5276 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5277 * @sta: currently connected station
5278 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5279 *
5280 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5281 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5282 * from a connected station was received.
5283 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5284 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5285 * serialized.
5286 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5287 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5288 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5289 * checks.
5290 */
5291 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5292
5293 /*
5294 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5295 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5296 */
5297 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5298
5299 /**
5300 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5301 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5302 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5303 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5304 *
5305 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5306 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5307 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5308 *
5309 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5310 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5311 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5312 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5313 *
5314 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5315 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5316 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5317 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5318 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5319 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5320 *
5321 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5322 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5323 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5324 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5325 * use this API.
5326 */
5327 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5328 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5329
5330 /**
5331 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5332 *
5333 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5334 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5335 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5336 *
5337 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5338 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5339 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5340 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5341 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5342 */
5343 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5344 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5345 struct sk_buff *skb,
5346 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5347 int max_rates);
5348
5349 /**
5350 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5351 *
5352 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5353 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5354 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5355 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5356 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5357 * slow stations to starve).
5358 *
5359 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5360 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5361 */
5362 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5363 u32 thr);
5364
5365 /**
5366 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5367 *
5368 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5369 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5370 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5371 *
5372 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5373 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5374 * @info: tx status information
5375 */
5376 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5377 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5378 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5379
5380 /**
5381 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5382 *
5383 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5384 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5385 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5386 *
5387 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5388 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5389 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5390 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5391 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5392 *
5393 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5394 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5395 */
5396 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5397 struct sk_buff *skb);
5398
5399 /**
5400 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5401 *
5402 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5403 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5404 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5405 *
5406 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5407 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5408 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5409 *
5410 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5411 * @status: tx status information
5412 */
5413 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5414 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5415
5416 /**
5417 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5418 *
5419 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5420 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5421 * specific skbs.
5422 *
5423 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5424 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5425 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5426 *
5427 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5428 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5429 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5430 * @info: tx status information
5431 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5432 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5433 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5434 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5435 {
5436 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5437 .sta = sta,
5438 .info = info,
5439 };
5440
5441 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5442 }
5443
5444 /**
5445 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5446 *
5447 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5448 *
5449 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5450 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5451 * for a single hardware.
5452 *
5453 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5454 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5455 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5456 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5457 struct sk_buff *skb)
5458 {
5459 local_bh_disable();
5460 ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5461 local_bh_enable();
5462 }
5463
5464 /**
5465 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5466 *
5467 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5468 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5469 *
5470 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5471 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5472 *
5473 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5474 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5475 */
5476 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5477 struct sk_buff *skb);
5478
5479 /**
5480 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5481 *
5482 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5483 * connected STA.
5484 *
5485 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5486 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5487 */
5488 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5489
5490 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5491
5492 /**
5493 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5494 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5495 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5496 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5497 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5498 * should be ignored.
5499 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5500 */
5501 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5502 u16 tim_offset;
5503 u16 tim_length;
5504
5505 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5506 u16 mbssid_off;
5507 };
5508
5509 /**
5510 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5511 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5512 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5513 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5514 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5515 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5516 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5517 *
5518 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5519 * obtain the beacon template.
5520 *
5521 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5522 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5523 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5524 * applicable, the CSA count.
5525 *
5526 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5527 *
5528 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5529 */
5530 struct sk_buff *
5531 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5532 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5533 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5534 unsigned int link_id);
5535
5536 /**
5537 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5538 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5539 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5540 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5541 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5542 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5543 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5544 *
5545 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5546 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5547 * requested index.
5548 *
5549 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5550 */
5551 struct sk_buff *
5552 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5553 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5554 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5555 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5556
5557 /**
5558 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5559 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5560 *
5561 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5562 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5563 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5564 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5565 */
5566 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5567 u8 cnt;
5568 struct {
5569 struct sk_buff *skb;
5570 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5571 } bcn[];
5572 };
5573
5574 /**
5575 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5576 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5577 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5578 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5579 *
5580 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5581 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5582 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5583 * one multiple BSSID element.
5584 *
5585 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5586 *
5587 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5588 * %NULL on error.
5589 */
5590 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5591 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5592 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5593 unsigned int link_id);
5594
5595 /**
5596 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5597 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5598 *
5599 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5600 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5601 */
5602 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5603
5604 /**
5605 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5606 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5607 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5608 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5609 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5610 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5611 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5612 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5613 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5614 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5615 *
5616 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5617 * obtain the beacon frame.
5618 *
5619 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5620 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5621 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5622 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5623 *
5624 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5625 *
5626 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5627 */
5628 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5629 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5630 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5631 unsigned int link_id);
5632
5633 /**
5634 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5635 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5636 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5637 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5638 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5639 *
5640 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5641 *
5642 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5643 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5644 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5645 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5646 unsigned int link_id)
5647 {
5648 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5649 }
5650
5651 /**
5652 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5653 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5654 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5655 *
5656 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5657 * This function is called implicitly when
5658 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5659 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5660 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5661 *
5662 * Return: new countdown value
5663 */
5664 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5665 unsigned int link_id);
5666
5667 /**
5668 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5669 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5670 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5671 *
5672 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5673 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5674 *
5675 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5676 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5677 */
5678 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5679
5680 /**
5681 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5682 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5683 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5684 *
5685 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5686 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5687 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5688 */
5689 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5690
5691 /**
5692 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5693 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5694 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5695 *
5696 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5697 */
5698 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5699 unsigned int link_id);
5700
5701 /**
5702 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5703 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5704 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5705 *
5706 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5707 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5708 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5709 */
5710 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5711
5712 /**
5713 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5714 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5715 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5716 *
5717 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5718 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5719 *
5720 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5721 *
5722 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5723 */
5724 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5725 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5726
5727 /**
5728 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5729 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5730 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5731 *
5732 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5733 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5734 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5735 *
5736 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5737 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5738 *
5739 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5740 */
5741 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5742 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5743
5744 /**
5745 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5746 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5747 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5748 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5749 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5750 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5751 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5752 * if at all possible
5753 *
5754 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5755 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5756 * BSSID and address is used.
5757 *
5758 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5759 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5760 *
5761 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5762 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5763 *
5764 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5765 */
5766 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5767 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5768 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5769
5770 /**
5771 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5772 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5773 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5774 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5775 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5776 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5777 *
5778 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5779 * hardware.
5780 *
5781 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5782 */
5783 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5784 const u8 *src_addr,
5785 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5786 size_t tailroom);
5787
5788 /**
5789 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5790 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5791 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5792 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5793 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5794 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5795 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5796 *
5797 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5798 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5799 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5800 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5801 */
5802 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5803 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5804 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5805 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5806
5807 /**
5808 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5809 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5810 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5811 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5812 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5813 *
5814 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5815 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5816 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5817 *
5818 * Return: The duration.
5819 */
5820 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5821 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5822 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5823
5824 /**
5825 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5826 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5827 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5828 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5829 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5830 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5831 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5832 *
5833 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5834 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5835 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5836 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5837 */
5838 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5839 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5840 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5841 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5842 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5843
5844 /**
5845 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5846 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5847 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5848 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5849 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5850 *
5851 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5852 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5853 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5854 *
5855 * Return: The duration.
5856 */
5857 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5858 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5859 size_t frame_len,
5860 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5861
5862 /**
5863 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5864 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5865 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5866 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5867 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5868 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5869 *
5870 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5871 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5872 *
5873 * Return: The duration.
5874 */
5875 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5876 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5877 enum nl80211_band band,
5878 size_t frame_len,
5879 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5880
5881 /**
5882 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5883 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5884 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5885 *
5886 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5887 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5888 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5889 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5890 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5891 *
5892 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5893 * frames are available.
5894 *
5895 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5896 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5897 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5898 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5899 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5900 * use common code for all beacons.
5901 */
5902 struct sk_buff *
5903 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5904
5905 /**
5906 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5907 *
5908 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5909 *
5910 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5911 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5912 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5913 */
5914 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5915 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5916
5917 /**
5918 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5919 *
5920 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5921 * from the given packet.
5922 *
5923 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5924 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5925 * with this P1K
5926 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5927 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5928 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5929 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5930 {
5931 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5932 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5933 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5934
5935 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5936 }
5937
5938 /**
5939 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5940 *
5941 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5942 * and transmitter address.
5943 *
5944 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5945 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5946 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5947 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5948 */
5949 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5950 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5951
5952 /**
5953 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5954 *
5955 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5956 * in the packet.
5957 *
5958 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5959 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5960 * encrypted with this key
5961 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5962 */
5963 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5964 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5965
5966 /**
5967 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5968 *
5969 * @pos: start of crypto header
5970 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5971 * @pn: PN to add
5972 *
5973 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5974 * the packet payload)
5975 *
5976 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5977 * point to the crypto header)
5978 */
5979 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5980
5981 /**
5982 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5983 *
5984 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5985 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5986 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5987 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5988 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5989 *
5990 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5991 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5992 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5993 *
5994 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5995 * can be done concurrently.
5996 */
5997 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5998 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5999
6000 /**
6001 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
6002 *
6003 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6004 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6005 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6006 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6007 * @seq: new sequence data
6008 *
6009 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
6010 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
6011 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
6012 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6013 *
6014 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6015 * can be done concurrently.
6016 */
6017 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6018 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6019
6020 /**
6021 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
6022 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6023 *
6024 * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
6025 *
6026 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
6027 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
6028 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
6029 */
6030 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6031
6032 /**
6033 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6034 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6035 * @keyconf: new key data
6036 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6037 *
6038 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6039 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6040 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6041 *
6042 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6043 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6044 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6045 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6046 *
6047 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6048 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6049 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6050 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6051 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6052 * of the reconfiguration.
6053 *
6054 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6055 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6056 *
6057 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6058 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
6059 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
6060 * the key that's being replaced.
6061 */
6062 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6063 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6064 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6065 int link_id);
6066
6067 /**
6068 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6069 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6070 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6071 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6072 * @gfp: allocation flags
6073 */
6074 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6075 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6076
6077 /**
6078 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6079 *
6080 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6081 * at the same time.
6082 *
6083 * @keyconf: the key in question
6084 */
6085 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6086
6087 /**
6088 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6089 *
6090 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6091 * at the same time.
6092 *
6093 * @keyconf: the key in question
6094 */
6095 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6096
6097 /**
6098 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6099 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6100 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6101 *
6102 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6103 */
6104 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6105
6106 /**
6107 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6108 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6109 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6110 *
6111 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6112 */
6113 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6114
6115 /**
6116 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6117 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6118 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6119 *
6120 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6121 *
6122 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6123 */
6124
6125 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6126
6127 /**
6128 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6129 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6130 *
6131 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6132 */
6133 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6134
6135 /**
6136 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6137 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6138 *
6139 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6140 */
6141 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6142
6143 /**
6144 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6145 *
6146 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6147 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6148 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6149 * any context, including hardirq context.
6150 *
6151 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6152 * @info: information about the completed scan
6153 */
6154 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6155 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6156
6157 /**
6158 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6159 *
6160 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6161 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6162 *
6163 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6164 */
6165 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6166
6167 /**
6168 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6169 *
6170 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6171 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6172 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6173 * while associating, for instance.
6174 *
6175 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6176 */
6177 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6178
6179 /**
6180 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6181 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6182 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6183 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6184 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6185 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6186 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6187 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6188 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6189 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6190 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6191 * for instance.
6192 */
6193 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6194 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
6195 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
6196 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
6197 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
6198 };
6199
6200 /**
6201 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6202 *
6203 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6204 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6205 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6206 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6207 *
6208 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6209 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6210 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6211 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6212 */
6213 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6214 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6215 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6216 void *data);
6217
6218 /**
6219 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6220 *
6221 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6222 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6223 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6224 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6225 * be used.
6226 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6227 *
6228 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6229 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6230 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6231 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6232 */
6233 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6234 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6235 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6236 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6237 void *data)
6238 {
6239 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6240 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6241 iterator, data);
6242 }
6243
6244 /**
6245 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6246 *
6247 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6248 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6249 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6250 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6251 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6252 *
6253 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6254 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6255 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6256 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6257 */
6258 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6259 u32 iter_flags,
6260 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6261 u8 *mac,
6262 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6263 void *data);
6264
6265 /**
6266 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6267 *
6268 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6269 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6270 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6271 *
6272 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6273 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6274 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6275 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6276 */
6277 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6278 u32 iter_flags,
6279 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6280 u8 *mac,
6281 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6282 void *data);
6283
6284 /**
6285 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6286 *
6287 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6288 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6289 * function for them.
6290 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6291 *
6292 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6293 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6294 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6295 */
6296 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6297 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6298 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6299 void *data);
6300
6301 /**
6302 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6303 *
6304 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6305 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6306 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6307 * mutex.
6308 *
6309 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6310 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6311 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6312 */
6313 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6314 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6315 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6316 void *data);
6317
6318 /**
6319 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6320 *
6321 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6322 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6323 *
6324 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6325 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6326 */
6327 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6328
6329 /**
6330 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6331 *
6332 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6333 * workqueue.
6334 *
6335 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6336 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6337 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6338 */
6339 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6340 struct delayed_work *dwork,
6341 unsigned long delay);
6342
6343 /**
6344 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6345 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6346 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6347 *
6348 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6349 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6350 * mac80211.
6351 *
6352 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6353 */
6354 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6355 u16 tid);
6356
6357 /**
6358 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6359 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6360 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6361 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6362 *
6363 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6364 *
6365 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6366 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6367 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6368 */
6369 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6370 u16 timeout);
6371
6372 /**
6373 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6374 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6375 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6376 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6377 *
6378 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6379 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6380 * from any context.
6381 */
6382 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6383 u16 tid);
6384
6385 /**
6386 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6387 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6388 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6389 *
6390 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6391 *
6392 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6393 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6394 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6395 */
6396 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6397
6398 /**
6399 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6400 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6401 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6402 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6403 *
6404 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6405 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6406 * can be called from any context.
6407 */
6408 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6409 u16 tid);
6410
6411 /**
6412 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6413 *
6414 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6415 * @addr: station's address
6416 *
6417 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6418 *
6419 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6420 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6421 */
6422 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6423 const u8 *addr);
6424
6425 /**
6426 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6427 *
6428 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6429 * @addr: remote station's address
6430 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6431 *
6432 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6433 *
6434 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6435 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6436 *
6437 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6438 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6439 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6440 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6441 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6442 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6443 * is not reliable.
6444 *
6445 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6446 */
6447 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6448 const u8 *addr,
6449 const u8 *localaddr);
6450
6451 /**
6452 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6453 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6454 * @addr: remote station's link address
6455 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6456 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6457 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6458 *
6459 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6460 *
6461 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6462 */
6463 struct ieee80211_sta *
6464 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6465 const u8 *addr,
6466 const u8 *localaddr,
6467 unsigned int *link_id);
6468
6469 /**
6470 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6471 * @hw: the hardware
6472 * @pubsta: the station
6473 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6474 *
6475 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6476 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6477 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6478 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6479 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6480 *
6481 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6482 * manner.
6483 *
6484 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6485 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6486 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6487 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6488 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6489 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6490 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6491 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6492 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6493 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6494 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6495 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6496 * woke up while blocked or not.
6497 */
6498 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6499 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6500
6501 /**
6502 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6503 * @pubsta: the station
6504 *
6505 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6506 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6507 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6508 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6509 *
6510 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6511 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6512 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6513 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6514 *
6515 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6516 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6517 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6518 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6519 */
6520 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6521
6522 /**
6523 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6524 * @pubsta: the station
6525 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6526 *
6527 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6528 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6529 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6530 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6531 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6532 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6533 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6534 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6535 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6536 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6537 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6538 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6539 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6540 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6541 */
6542 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6543
6544 /**
6545 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6546 * @pubsta: the station
6547 *
6548 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6549 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6550 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6551 *
6552 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6553 * there is no need to call this function.
6554 */
6555 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6556
6557 /**
6558 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6559 *
6560 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6561 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6562 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6563 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6564 *
6565 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6566 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6567 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6568 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6569 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6570 * attempts.
6571 *
6572 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6573 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6574 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6575 * them to 0.
6576 *
6577 * @pubsta: the station
6578 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6579 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6580 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6581 */
6582 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6583 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6584
6585 /**
6586 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6587 *
6588 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6589 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6590 *
6591 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6592 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6593 */
6594 bool
6595 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6596
6597 /**
6598 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6599 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6600 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6601 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6602 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6603 *
6604 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6605 *
6606 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6607 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6608 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6609 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6610 *
6611 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6612 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6613 * set_key callback.
6614 */
6615 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6616 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6617 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6618 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6619 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6620 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6621 void *data),
6622 void *iter_data);
6623
6624 /**
6625 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6626 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6627 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6628 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6629 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6630 *
6631 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6632 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6633 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6634 * in removal process will be skipped.
6635 *
6636 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6637 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6638 */
6639 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6640 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6641 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6642 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6643 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6644 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6645 void *data),
6646 void *iter_data);
6647
6648 /**
6649 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6650 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6651 * @iter: iterator function
6652 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6653 *
6654 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6655 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6656 * places while calling into the driver.
6657 *
6658 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6659 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6660 * removed.
6661 *
6662 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6663 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6664 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6665 * or not.
6666 */
6667 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6668 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6669 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6670 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6671 void *data),
6672 void *iter_data);
6673
6674 /**
6675 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx - iterate channel contexts
6676 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6677 * @iter: iterator function
6678 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6679 *
6680 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function can only be used while
6681 * holding the wiphy mutex.
6682 *
6683 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6684 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6685 * removed.
6686 *
6687 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6688 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6689 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6690 * or not.
6691 */
6692 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx(
6693 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6694 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6695 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6696 void *data),
6697 void *iter_data);
6698
6699 /**
6700 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6701 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6702 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6703 *
6704 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6705 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6706 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6707 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6708 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6709 * %NULL.
6710 *
6711 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6712 */
6713 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6714 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6715
6716 /**
6717 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6718 *
6719 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6720 *
6721 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6722 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6723 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6724 */
6725 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6726
6727 /**
6728 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6729 *
6730 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6731 *
6732 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6733 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6734 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6735 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6736 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6737 *
6738 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6739 * without connection recovery attempts.
6740 */
6741 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6742
6743 /**
6744 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6745 *
6746 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6747 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6748 *
6749 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6750 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6751 */
6752 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6753
6754 /**
6755 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6756 *
6757 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6758 *
6759 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6760 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6761 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6762 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6763 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6764 *
6765 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6766 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6767 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6768 * disconnect normally later.
6769 *
6770 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6771 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6772 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6773 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6774 */
6775 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6776
6777 /**
6778 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6779 * hardware restart
6780 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6781 *
6782 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6783 * hardware restart.
6784 */
6785 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6786
6787 /**
6788 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6789 * rssi threshold triggered
6790 *
6791 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6792 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6793 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6794 * @gfp: context flags
6795 *
6796 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6797 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6798 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6799 */
6800 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6801 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6802 s32 rssi_level,
6803 gfp_t gfp);
6804
6805 /**
6806 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6807 *
6808 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6809 * @gfp: context flags
6810 */
6811 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6812
6813 /**
6814 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6815 *
6816 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6817 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6818 * pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6819 */
6820 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6821 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6822
6823 /**
6824 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6825 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6826 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6827 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6828 * false.
6829 *
6830 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6831 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6832 */
6833 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6834 unsigned int link_id);
6835
6836 /**
6837 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6838 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6839 *
6840 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6841 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6842 * a deauth frame in this case.
6843 */
6844 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6845
6846 /**
6847 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6848 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6849 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6850 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6851 *
6852 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6853 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6854 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6855 */
6856 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6857 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6858
6859 /**
6860 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6861 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6862 */
6863 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6864
6865 /**
6866 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6867 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6868 */
6869 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6870
6871 /**
6872 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6873 *
6874 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6875 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6876 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6877 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6878 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6879 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6880 *
6881 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6882 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6883 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6884 */
6885 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6886 const u8 *addr);
6887
6888 /**
6889 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6890 * @pubsta: station struct
6891 * @tid: the session's TID
6892 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6893 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
6894 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6895 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6896 *
6897 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6898 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6899 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6900 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6901 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6902 */
6903 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6904 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6905 u16 received_mpdus);
6906
6907 /**
6908 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6909 *
6910 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6911 * buffer.
6912 *
6913 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6914 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6915 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6916 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6917 */
6918 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6919
6920 /**
6921 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6922 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6923 * @addr: station mac address
6924 * @tid: the rx tid
6925 */
6926 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6927 unsigned int tid);
6928
6929 /**
6930 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6931 *
6932 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6933 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6934 * reordering.
6935 *
6936 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6937 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6938 *
6939 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6940 * @addr: station mac address
6941 * @tid: the rx tid
6942 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6943 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6944 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6945 {
6946 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6947 return;
6948 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6949 }
6950
6951 /**
6952 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6953 *
6954 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6955 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6956 * reordering.
6957 *
6958 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6959 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6960 *
6961 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6962 * @addr: station mac address
6963 * @tid: the rx tid
6964 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6965 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6966 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6967 {
6968 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6969 return;
6970 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6971 }
6972
6973 /**
6974 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6975 *
6976 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6977 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6978 *
6979 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6980 *
6981 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6982 * @addr: station mac address
6983 * @tid: the rx tid
6984 */
6985 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6986 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6987
6988 /* Rate control API */
6989
6990 /**
6991 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6992 *
6993 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6994 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6995 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6996 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6997 * to be filled in
6998 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6999 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
7000 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
7001 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
7002 * RTS threshold
7003 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
7004 * if the selected rate supports it
7005 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
7006 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
7007 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
7008 */
7009 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
7010 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
7011 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
7012 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
7013 struct sk_buff *skb;
7014 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
7015 bool rts, short_preamble;
7016 u32 rate_idx_mask;
7017 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
7018 bool bss;
7019 };
7020
7021 /**
7022 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
7023 */
7024 enum rate_control_capabilities {
7025 /**
7026 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
7027 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
7028 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
7029 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
7030 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
7031 */
7032 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
7033 /**
7034 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
7035 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
7036 */
7037 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7038 };
7039
7040 struct rate_control_ops {
7041 unsigned long capa;
7042 const char *name;
7043 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7044 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7045 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7046 void (*free)(void *priv);
7047
7048 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7049 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7050 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7051 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7052 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7053 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7054 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7055 u32 changed);
7056 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7057 void *priv_sta);
7058
7059 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7060 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7061 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7062 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7063 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7064 struct sk_buff *skb);
7065 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7066 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7067
7068 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7069 struct dentry *dir);
7070
7071 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7072 };
7073
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7074 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7075 enum nl80211_band band,
7076 int index)
7077 {
7078 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7079 }
7080
7081 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7082 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7083 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7084 {
7085 int i;
7086
7087 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7088 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7089 return i;
7090
7091 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7092 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7093
7094 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7095 return 0;
7096 }
7097
7098 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7099 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7100 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7101 {
7102 unsigned int i;
7103
7104 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7105 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7106 return true;
7107 return false;
7108 }
7109
7110 /**
7111 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7112 *
7113 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7114 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7115 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7116 * the most recent rate control module decision.
7117 *
7118 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7119 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7120 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7121 *
7122 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7123 */
7124 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7125 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7126 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7127
7128 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7129 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7130
7131 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7132 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7133 {
7134 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7135 }
7136
7137 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7138 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7139 {
7140 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7141 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7142 }
7143
7144 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7145 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7146 {
7147 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7148 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7149 }
7150
7151 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7152 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7153 {
7154 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7155 }
7156
7157 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7158 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7159 {
7160 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7161 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7162 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7163 }
7164
7165 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7166 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7167 {
7168 if (p2p) {
7169 switch (type) {
7170 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7171 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7172 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7173 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7174 default:
7175 break;
7176 }
7177 }
7178 return type;
7179 }
7180
7181 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7182 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7183 {
7184 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7185 }
7186
7187 /**
7188 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7189 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7190 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7191 *
7192 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7193 */
7194 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7195 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7196 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7197 {
7198 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7199 }
7200
7201 /**
7202 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7203 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7204 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7205 *
7206 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7207 */
7208 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7209 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7210 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7211 {
7212 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7213 }
7214
7215 /**
7216 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7217 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7218 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7219 *
7220 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7221 */
7222 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7223 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7224 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7225 {
7226 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7227 }
7228
7229 /**
7230 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7231 *
7232 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7233 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7234 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7235 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7236 *
7237 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7238 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7239 * matching GroupId management frame.
7240 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7241 */
7242 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7243 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7244
7245 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7246 int rssi_min_thold,
7247 int rssi_max_thold);
7248
7249 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7250
7251 /**
7252 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7253 *
7254 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7255 *
7256 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7257 *
7258 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7259 * applicable.
7260 */
7261 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7262
7263 /**
7264 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7265 * @vif: virtual interface
7266 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7267 * @gfp: allocation flags
7268 *
7269 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7270 */
7271 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7272 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7273 gfp_t gfp);
7274
7275 /**
7276 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7277 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7278 * @vif: virtual interface
7279 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7280 * @band: the band to transmit on
7281 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7282 *
7283 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7284 *
7285 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7286 */
7287 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7288 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7289 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7290
7291 /**
7292 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7293 * of injected frames.
7294 *
7295 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7296 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7297 * of the skb before calling this function.
7298 *
7299 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7300 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7301 *
7302 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7303 */
7304 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7305 struct net_device *dev);
7306
7307 /**
7308 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7309 *
7310 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7311 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7312 *
7313 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7314 *
7315 * private:
7316 *
7317 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7318 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7319 */
7320 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7321 u32 next_tsf;
7322 bool has_next_tsf;
7323
7324 u8 absent;
7325
7326 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7327 struct {
7328 u32 start;
7329 u32 duration;
7330 u32 interval;
7331 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7332 };
7333
7334 /**
7335 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7336 *
7337 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7338 * @data: NoA tracking data
7339 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7340 *
7341 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7342 */
7343 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7344 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7345
7346 /**
7347 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7348 *
7349 * @data: NoA tracking data
7350 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7351 */
7352 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7353
7354 /**
7355 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7356 * @vif: virtual interface
7357 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7358 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7359 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7360 * @gfp: allocation flags
7361 *
7362 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7363 */
7364 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7365 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7366 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7367
7368 /**
7369 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7370 *
7371 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7372 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7373 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7374 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7375 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7376 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7377 *
7378 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7379 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7380 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7381 *
7382 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7383 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7384 *
7385 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7386 */
7387 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7388
7389 /**
7390 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7391 *
7392 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7393 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7394 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7395 *
7396 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7397 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7398 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7399 *
7400 * @sta: the station
7401 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7402 */
7403 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7404
7405 /**
7406 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7407 *
7408 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7409 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7410 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7411 *
7412 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7413 *
7414 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7415 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7416 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7417 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7418 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7419 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7420 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7421 *
7422 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7423 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7424 */
7425 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7426 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7427
7428 /**
7429 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7430 * (in process context)
7431 *
7432 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7433 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7434 *
7435 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7436 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7437 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7438 *
7439 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7440 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7441 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7442 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7443 {
7444 struct sk_buff *skb;
7445
7446 local_bh_disable();
7447 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7448 local_bh_enable();
7449
7450 return skb;
7451 }
7452
7453 /**
7454 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7455 *
7456 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7457 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7458 *
7459 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7460 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7461 */
7462 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7463 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7464
7465 /**
7466 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7467 *
7468 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7469 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7470 *
7471 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7472 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7473 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7474 */
7475 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7476
7477 /**
7478 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7479 *
7480 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7481 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7482 *
7483 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7484 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7485 */
7486 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7487
7488 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7489 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7490 {
7491 }
7492
7493 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7494 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7495
7496 /**
7497 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7498 *
7499 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7500 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7501 *
7502 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7503 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7504 *
7505 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7506 * this TXQ internally.
7507 */
7508 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7509 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7510 {
7511 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7512 }
7513
7514 /**
7515 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7516 *
7517 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7518 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7519 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7520 *
7521 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7522 * internally.
7523 */
7524 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7525 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7526 bool force)
7527 {
7528 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7529 }
7530
7531 /**
7532 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7533 *
7534 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7535 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7536 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7537 * next_txq().
7538 *
7539 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7540 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7541 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7542 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7543 * again.
7544 *
7545 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7546 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7547 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7548 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7549 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7550 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7551 *
7552 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7553 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7554 *
7555 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7556 */
7557 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7558 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7559
7560 /**
7561 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7562 *
7563 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7564 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7565 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7566 *
7567 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7568 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7569 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7570 */
7571 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7572 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7573 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7574
7575 /**
7576 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7577 *
7578 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7579 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7580 *
7581 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7582 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7583 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7584 * @gfp: allocation flags
7585 */
7586 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7587 u8 inst_id,
7588 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7589 gfp_t gfp);
7590
7591 /**
7592 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7593 *
7594 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7595 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7596 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7597 *
7598 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7599 * @match: match event information
7600 * @gfp: allocation flags
7601 */
7602 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7603 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7604 gfp_t gfp);
7605
7606 /**
7607 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7608 *
7609 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7610 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7611 *
7612 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7613 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7614 * information.
7615 * @len: frame length in bytes
7616 *
7617 * Return: the airtime estimate
7618 */
7619 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7620 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7621 int len);
7622
7623 /**
7624 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7625 *
7626 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7627 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7628 *
7629 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7630 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7631 * @len: frame length in bytes
7632 *
7633 * Return: the airtime estimate
7634 */
7635 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7636 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7637 int len);
7638 /**
7639 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7640 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7641 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7642 *
7643 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7644 *
7645 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7646 */
7647 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7648 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7649
7650 /**
7651 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7652 * probe response template.
7653 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7654 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7655 *
7656 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7657 *
7658 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7659 */
7660 struct sk_buff *
7661 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7662 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7663
7664 /**
7665 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7666 * collision.
7667 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7668 *
7669 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7670 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7671 * aware of.
7672 */
7673 void
7674 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7675 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7676
7677 /**
7678 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7679 *
7680 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7681 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7682 *
7683 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7684 *
7685 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7686 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7687 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7688 {
7689 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7690 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7691
7692 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7693 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7694 }
7695
7696 /**
7697 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7698 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7699 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7700 *
7701 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7702 * back into the driver.
7703 *
7704 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7705 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7706 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7707 *
7708 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7709 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7710 * a sequence of calls like
7711 *
7712 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
7713 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7714 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7715 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7716 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7717 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7718 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7719 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7720 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
7721 *
7722 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7723 */
7724 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7725
7726 /**
7727 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7728 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7729 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7730 *
7731 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7732 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7733 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7734 * completed after it returns.
7735 */
7736 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7737 u16 active_links);
7738
7739 /**
7740 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7741 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7742 *
7743 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7744 * TTLM request.
7745 */
7746 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7747
7748 /**
7749 * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
7750 * @width: the channel width value to convert
7751 * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
7752 */
7753 static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)7754 ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
7755 {
7756 switch (width) {
7757 default:
7758 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7759 fallthrough;
7760 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
7761 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
7762 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
7763 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
7764 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
7765 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
7766 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
7767 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
7768 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
7769 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
7770 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
7771 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
7772 }
7773 }
7774
7775 /**
7776 * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
7777 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
7778 * @bw: the bandwidth requested
7779 *
7780 * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
7781 * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
7782 * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
7783 *
7784 * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
7785 * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
7786 * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
7787 * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
7788 *
7789 * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
7790 * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
7791 * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
7792 *
7793 * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
7794 * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
7795 * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
7796 * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
7797 *
7798 * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
7799 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
7800 * case of HW restart.
7801 *
7802 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
7803 * into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
7804 *
7805 * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
7806 */
7807 bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
7808 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);
7809
7810 /**
7811 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
7812 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
7813 *
7814 * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
7815 * as well.
7816 */
7817 void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);
7818
7819 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7820 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7821 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7822 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7823 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7824 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7825 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7826 u32 changed);
7827 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7828 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7829 int n_vifs,
7830 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7831
7832 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7833